blob: 15e0f7f1c772aa97d08aa88e6e2b2599d5d6ec2a [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Sema.h"
15#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000032#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
33#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek1ddd6d22010-07-21 20:43:11 +000062 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000462Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000463Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000464 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000465 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
466 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
467}
468
469/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
470Sema::OwningExprResult
471Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
472 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
473 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000474 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000475 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000476 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000477 << D->getDeclName();
478 return ExprError();
479 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000480
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000481 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000482 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
483 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
484 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000485 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000486 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000487 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
488 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000489 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
490 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000491 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000493 << D->getIdentifier();
494 return ExprError();
495 }
496 }
497 }
498 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000500 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000501
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000502 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
503 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
504 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000505 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000506}
507
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000508/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
509/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
510/// actual member.
511///
512/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
513/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
514/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
515/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
516/// we found.
517///
518/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
519/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
520/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
521VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
522 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000523 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
524 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
525 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
526
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000527 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000528 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
529 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
530 do {
531 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000532 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000533 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 else {
536 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
537 break;
538 }
539 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000540 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000541 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000542
543 return BaseObject;
544}
545
546Sema::OwningExprResult
547Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
548 FieldDecl *Field,
549 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
550 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
551 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000552 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000553 AnonFields);
554
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
556 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
557 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
558 // found via name lookup.
559 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000560 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 if (BaseObject) {
562 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
563 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000564 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000565 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000566 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 BaseQuals
568 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000569 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
570 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
571 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
572 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
573 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000574 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
576 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
577 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000578 BaseQuals
579 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 } else {
581 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
582 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
583 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000584 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
585 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000587 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000588 = Context.getTagDeclType(
589 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
590 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000591 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
593 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
594 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000595 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000596 MD->getThisType(Context),
597 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
599 }
600 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000601 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
602 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000603 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000604 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 }
606
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000607 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
611
612 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
613 // anonymous struct/union.
614 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000615 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000616 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
617 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
618 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
619 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000620 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
621 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
622
623 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
624 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
625 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
626 ResultQuals.removeConst();
627
628 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
629 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
630
631 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
632 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
633
634 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
635 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
636 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
637
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000638 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000639 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000640 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000641 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
642 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000643 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000644 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000645 }
646
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000647 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000648}
649
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000650/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000651/// possibly a list of template arguments.
652///
653/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
654/// DecomposeTemplateName.
655///
656/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
657/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
658/// some way.
659static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
660 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
661 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000662 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000663 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
664 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
665 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
666 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
667
668 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
669 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
670 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
671 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
672 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
673
674 TemplateName TName =
675 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000676 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
677 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000678 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
679 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000680 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000681 TemplateArgs = 0;
682 }
683}
684
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000685/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
686/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
687/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000688static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000689 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
690 return false;
691
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000692 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
693 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
694 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
695 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
696 if (!BaseRT) return false;
697
698 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000699 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000700 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
701 return false;
702 }
703
704 return true;
705}
706
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000707/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
708/// the prospective base classes.
709static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
710 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
711 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000712 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000713 return false;
714
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000715 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000716 if (!RD) return false;
717 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
720 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
721 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
722 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
723 if (!BaseRT) return false;
724
725 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000726 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
727 return false;
728 }
729
730 return true;
731}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000732
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000733enum IMAKind {
734 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
735 IMA_Static,
736
737 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
738 IMA_Mixed,
739
740 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
741 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
742 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
743
744 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
745 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
746 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
747
748 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
749 IMA_Instance,
750
751 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
752 IMA_Unresolved,
753
754 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
755 /// context is not an instance method.
756 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
757
758 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
759 /// non-class context.
760 IMA_AnonymousMember,
761
762 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
763 /// context is not an instance method.
764 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
765
766 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
767 /// class.
768 IMA_Error_Unrelated
769};
770
771/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
772/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
773/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
774/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
775/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
776/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
777static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
778 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000779 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000781 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000782 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000783 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
784 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000785
786 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
787 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
788
789 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
790 bool hasNonInstance = false;
791 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
792 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000793 NamedDecl *D = *I;
794 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000795 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
796
797 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
798 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
799 // that's a special case.
800 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
801 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
802 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
803 }
804 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
805 }
806 else
807 hasNonInstance = true;
808 }
809
810 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
811 // member reference.
812 if (Classes.empty())
813 return IMA_Static;
814
815 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
816 // an implicit member reference.
817 if (isStaticContext)
818 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
819
820 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
821 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
822 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
823 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000824 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000825 Classes))
826 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
827
828 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
829}
830
831/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
832static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
833 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
834 const LookupResult &R) {
835 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
836 SourceRange Range(Loc);
837 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
838
839 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
840 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
841 if (MD->isStatic()) {
842 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
843 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
844 << Range << R.getLookupName();
845 return;
846 }
847 }
848
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
850 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
851 return;
852 }
853
854 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000855}
856
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000857/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
858///
859/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000860bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
861 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000862 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
863
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000864 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000865 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000866 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
867 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000868 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
871 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
874 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
875 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
876 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000877 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000878 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000879 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
880 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
881
882 if (!R.empty()) {
883 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
884 R.suppressDiagnostics();
885
886 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
887 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
888 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
889 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
890
891 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
892 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
893 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000894 if (isInstance) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000895 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000896 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000897
898 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
899 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
900 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
901 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
902 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
903 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(R.getNameLoc(),
904 DepThisType, false);
905 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
906 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
907 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
908 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
909 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
910 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000911 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
912 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000913 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
914 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000915 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000916 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000917
918 // Do we really want to note all of these?
919 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
920 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
921
922 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
923 return false;
924 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000925
926 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 }
928 }
929
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000930 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000931 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000932 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000933 if (!R.empty()) {
934 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
935 if (SS.isEmpty())
936 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
937 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
938 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
939 else
940 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
941 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
942 << SS.getRange()
943 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
944 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
945 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
946 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
947 << ND->getDeclName();
948
949 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
950 return false;
951 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000952
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000953 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
954 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
955 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
956 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
957 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
958 // to recover well anyway.
959 if (SS.isEmpty())
960 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
961 else
962 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
963 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
964 << SS.getRange();
965
966 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
967 return true;
968 }
969 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000970 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000971 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000972 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000974 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000975 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000976 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
977 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000978 return true;
979 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000980 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000981 }
982
983 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
984 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
985 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
988 << SS.getRange();
989 return true;
990 }
991
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000992 // Give up, we can't recover.
993 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
994 return true;
995}
996
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +0000997static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +0000998 IdentifierInfo *II,
999 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001000 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1001 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1002 if (!IDecl)
1003 return 0;
1004 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1005 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1006 return 0;
1007 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1008 if (!property)
1009 return 0;
1010 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1011 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1012 return 0;
1013 return property;
1014}
1015
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001016static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001017 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001018 IdentifierInfo *II,
1019 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1020 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001021 bool LookForIvars;
1022 if (Lookup.empty())
1023 LookForIvars = true;
1024 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1025 LookForIvars = false;
1026 else
1027 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1028 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1029 if (!LookForIvars)
1030 return 0;
1031
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001032 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1033 if (!IDecl)
1034 return 0;
1035 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001036 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1037 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001038 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1039 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1040 if (!property)
1041 return 0;
1042 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1043 DynamicImplSeen =
1044 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1045 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001046 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1047 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001048 NameLoc,
1049 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1050 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1051 (Expr *)0, true);
1052 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1053 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1054 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1055 return Ivar;
1056 }
1057 return 0;
1058}
1059
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001061 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001062 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1063 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1064 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1065 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1066 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1067
1068 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001069 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001070
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001071 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072
1073 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001074 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001076 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001077
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001078 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001079 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001080 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001081
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1083 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001084 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1085 // (note: handled after lookup)
1086 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1087 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1088 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001089 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1090 // names a dependent type.
1091 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1092 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001093 bool DependentID = false;
1094 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1095 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1096 DependentID = true;
1097 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1098 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1099 if (DC) {
1100 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1101 return ExprError();
1102 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1103 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1104 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1105 } else {
1106 DependentID = true;
1107 }
1108 }
1109
1110 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001111 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001112 TemplateArgs);
1113 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001114 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001115 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001116 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001117 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001118 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1119 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1120 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1121 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1122 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001123 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1124 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1125 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001127 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001128 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001129
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001130 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1131 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001132 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1133 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001134 if (E.isInvalid())
1135 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001136
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1138 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001139 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1140 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001141 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001142 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1143 isAddressOfOperand);
1144 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001145 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1146 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001147 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001148 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001149
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001150 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1151 return ExprError();
1152
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001153 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1154 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001155 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001156
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001158 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001159 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1160 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1161 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1162 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1163 }
1164
1165 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1166 // call, diagnose the problem.
1167 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001168 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001169 return ExprError();
1170
1171 assert(!R.empty() &&
1172 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001173
1174 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1175 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001176 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001177 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1178 R.clear();
1179 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1180 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1181 return move(E);
1182 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001183 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001184 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001185
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001186 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1187 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1188
1189 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001190 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001191 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1192 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001193 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1194 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1195 if (Property) {
1196 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1197 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001198 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001199 }
1200 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001201 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001202 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1203 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1204 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1205 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1206 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1207 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001208 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001209 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001210
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001211 QualType T = Func->getType();
1212 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001213 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001214 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1215 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001217 }
1218 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001219
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001220 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1221 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1222 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1223 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1224 // class member access expression.
1225 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1226 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001227 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001228 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001229 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1230 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001231 }
1232
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001233 if (TemplateArgs)
1234 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001235
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1237}
1238
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001239/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1240Sema::OwningExprResult
1241Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1242 LookupResult &R,
1243 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1244 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1245 case IMA_Instance:
1246 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1247
1248 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1249 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1250 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1251 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1252
1253 case IMA_Mixed:
1254 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1255 case IMA_Unresolved:
1256 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1257
1258 case IMA_Static:
1259 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1260 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1261 if (TemplateArgs)
1262 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1263 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1264
1265 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1266 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1267 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1268 return ExprError();
1269 }
1270
1271 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1272 return ExprError();
1273}
1274
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001275/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1276/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1277/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1278/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001279Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001280Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001281 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001282 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001283 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001284 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001285
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001286 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001287 return ExprError();
1288
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001289 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001290 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1291
1292 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1293 return ExprError();
1294
1295 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001296 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1297 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001298 return ExprError();
1299 }
1300
1301 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1302}
1303
1304/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1305/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1306/// additional lookup.
1307///
1308/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1309/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1310///
1311/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1312Sema::OwningExprResult
1313Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001314 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001315 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001316 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001317
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001318 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1319 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1320 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1321 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1322 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1323
1324 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1325 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1326 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001327 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001328
1329 bool LookForIvars;
1330 if (Lookup.empty())
1331 LookForIvars = true;
1332 else if (IsClassMethod)
1333 LookForIvars = false;
1334 else
1335 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1336 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001337 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001338 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001339 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001340 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1341 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1342 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1343 if (IsClassMethod)
1344 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1345 << IV->getDeclName());
1346
1347 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1348 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1349 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1350 return ExprError();
1351
1352 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1353 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1354 return ExprError();
1355
1356 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1357 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1358 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1359 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1360
1361 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1362 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1363 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1364 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001365 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001366 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1367 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1368 SelfName, false, false);
1369 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1370 return Owned(new (Context)
1371 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1372 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1373 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001374 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001375 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1378 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1379 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1380 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1381 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1382 }
1383 }
1384
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001385 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1386 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1387 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1388 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1389 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1390 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1391 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1392 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1393 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1394 }
1395 }
1396 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1398 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001399}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001400
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001401/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1402///
1403/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1404///
1405/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1406/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1407/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1408/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1409///
1410/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1411/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1412/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1413/// the class declaring the member.
1414///
1415/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1416/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1417/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001418bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001419Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1420 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001421 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001422 NamedDecl *Member) {
1423 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1424 if (!RD)
1425 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001426
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001427 QualType DestRecordType;
1428 QualType DestType;
1429 QualType FromRecordType;
1430 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1431 bool PointerConversions = false;
1432 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1433 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001434
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001435 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1436 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1437 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1438 PointerConversions = true;
1439 } else {
1440 DestType = DestRecordType;
1441 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001442 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001443 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1444 if (Method->isStatic())
1445 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001446
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001447 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1448 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001449
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001450 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1451 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1452 PointerConversions = true;
1453 } else {
1454 FromRecordType = FromType;
1455 DestType = DestRecordType;
1456 }
1457 } else {
1458 // No conversion necessary.
1459 return false;
1460 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001461
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001462 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1463 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001464
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001465 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1466 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001469 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1470 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1471
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001472 ImplicitCastExpr::ResultCategory Category = CastCategory(From);
1473
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001474 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001475 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 // class name.
1477 //
1478 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1479 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1480 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1481 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1482 //
1483 // class Base { public: int x; };
1484 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1485 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1486 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1487 //
1488 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1489 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1490 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1491 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001493 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1494 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1495 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1496
1497 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1498
1499 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1500 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1501 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1502 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001503 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001504 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001505 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001506 return true;
1507
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001508 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001510 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001511 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001512
1513 FromType = QType;
1514 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1515
1516 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1517 // we're done.
1518 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1519 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001520 }
1521 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001523 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001524
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001525 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1526 // down to the using declaration's type.
1527 //
1528 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1529 // class ever has member declarations.
1530 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1531 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1532 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1533 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1534
1535 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1536 // conversion is non-trivial.
1537 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1538 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001539 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001540 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001541 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001542 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001543
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001544 QualType UType = URecordType;
1545 if (PointerConversions)
1546 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001547 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001548 Category, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001549 FromType = UType;
1550 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1551 }
1552
1553 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1554 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1555 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001556 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001557
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001558 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001559 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1560 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001561 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001564 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001565 Category, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001566 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001567}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001568
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001569/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001570static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001571 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001572 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001573 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1574 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001575 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1576 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1577 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001578 if (SS.isSet()) {
1579 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1580 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001581 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001582
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001583 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001584 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1585 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001586}
1587
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001588/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1589/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1590/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1591/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001592Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001593Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1594 LookupResult &R,
1595 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1596 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001597 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1598
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001599 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001600
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001601 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1602 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001603 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001604 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001605 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001606 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001607 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001608
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001609 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1610 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001611 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1612 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001613 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1614 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001615 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1616 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1617 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1618 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001619 }
1620
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001621 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1622 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1623 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001624 SS,
1625 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1626 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001627}
1628
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001629bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001630 const LookupResult &R,
1631 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001632 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1633 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1634 return false;
1635
1636 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001637 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001638 return false;
1639
1640 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001641 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001642 return false;
1643
1644 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1645 // normal lookup:
1646 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1647 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1648
1649 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1650 // -- a declaration of a class member
1651 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1652 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001653 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001654 return false;
1655
1656 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1657 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1658 // using-declaration
1659 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1660 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1661 // turn off ADL anyway).
1662 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1663 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1664 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1665 return false;
1666
1667 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1668 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1669 // template
1670 // And also for builtin functions.
1671 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1672 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1673
1674 // But also builtin functions.
1675 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1676 return false;
1677 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1678 return false;
1679 }
1680
1681 return true;
1682}
1683
1684
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001685/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1686/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1687/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1688/// will in fact be used.
1689static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1690 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1691 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1692 return true;
1693 }
1694
1695 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1696 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1697 return true;
1698 }
1699
1700 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1701 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1702 return true;
1703 }
1704
1705 return false;
1706}
1707
1708Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001709Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001710 LookupResult &R,
1711 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001712 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1713 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001714 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001715 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1716 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001717
1718 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1719 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1720 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001721 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1722 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001723 return ExprError();
1724
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001725 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1726 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1727 // we've picked a target.
1728 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1729
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001730 bool Dependent
1731 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001732 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001733 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001734 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001735 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001736 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1737 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001738
1739 return Owned(ULE);
1740}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001741
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001742
1743/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1744Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001745Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001746 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1747 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001748 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001749 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1750 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001751
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001752 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001753 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1754 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001755
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001756 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1757 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1758 // a template argument list.
1759 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1760 << Template << SS.getRange();
1761 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1762 return ExprError();
1763 }
1764
1765 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1766 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1767 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001768 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001769 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001770 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001771 return ExprError();
1772 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001773
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001774 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1775 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1776 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1777 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001778 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001779 return ExprError();
1780
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001781 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1782 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001783 return ExprError();
1784
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001785 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1786 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1787 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1788 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001789 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001790 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1791 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1792 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001793 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001794 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001795 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1796 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1797 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1798 return ExprError();
1799 }
1800
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001801 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001802 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1803 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1804 return ExprError();
1805 }
1806
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001807 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001808 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001809 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001810 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001811 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001812 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1813 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001814 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001815
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001816 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001817 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001818 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1819 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001820 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001821 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1822 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1823 Expr *E = new (Context)
1824 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1825 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001826
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001827 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
1828 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001829 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001830 SourceLocation(),
1831 Owned(E));
1832 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
1833 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
1834 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1835 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1836 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001837 }
1838 }
1839 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001840 }
1841 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1842 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001843
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001844 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1845 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001846}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001847
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001848Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1849 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001850 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001851
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001852 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001853 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001854 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1855 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1856 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001857 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001858
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001859 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1860 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001861
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001862 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001863 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1864 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001865 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001866 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001867 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001868 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001869
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001870 QualType ResTy;
1871 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1872 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1873 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001874 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001875
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001876 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001877 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001878 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1879 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001880 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001881}
1882
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001883Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001884 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001885 bool Invalid = false;
1886 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1887 if (Invalid)
1888 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001889
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001890 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1891 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001892 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001894
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001895 QualType Ty;
1896 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1897 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1898 else if (Literal.isWide())
1899 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001900 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1901 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001902 else
1903 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001904
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001905 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1906 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001907 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001908}
1909
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1911 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001912 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1913 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001914 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001915 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001916 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001917 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001918 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001919
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001920 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001921 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1922 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001923 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001924
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001925 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001926 bool Invalid = false;
1927 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1928 if (Invalid)
1929 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001931 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001932 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001933 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934 return ExprError();
1935
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001936 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001937
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001938 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001939 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001940 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001941 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001942 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001943 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001944 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001945 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001946
1947 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1948
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001949 using llvm::APFloat;
1950 APFloat Val(Format);
1951
1952 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001953
1954 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1955 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1956 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1957 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001958 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001959 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001960 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001961 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001962 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1963 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001964 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001965 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1966 }
1967
1968 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1969 << Ty
1970 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1971 }
1972
1973 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001974 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001976 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001977 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001978 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001979 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001980
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001981 // long long is a C99 feature.
1982 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001983 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001984 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1985
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001986 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001987 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001988
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001989 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1990 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1991 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001992 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1993 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001994 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001995 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001996 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1997 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001998
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001999 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2000 // be an unsigned int.
2001 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2002
2003 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002004 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002005 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2006 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002007 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002008
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002009 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2010 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2011 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2012 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002013 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002014 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002015 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002016 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002017 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002018 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002020 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002021 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002022 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002023
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002024 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2025 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2026 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2027 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002028 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002029 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002030 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002031 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002032 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002033 }
2034
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002035 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002036 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002037 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002038
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002039 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2040 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2041 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2042 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002043 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002044 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002045 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002047 }
2048 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002049
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002050 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2051 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002052 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002053 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002054 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002055 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002056 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002057
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2059 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002061 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002062 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002063
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002064 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2065 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002067 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002068
2069 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002070}
2071
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002072Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2073 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002074 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002075 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002076 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002077}
2078
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002079/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002080/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002081bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002082 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2083 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2084 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002085 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2086 return false;
2087
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002088 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2089 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2090 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2091 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2092 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2093 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2094
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002095 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002096 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002097 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002098 if (isSizeof)
2099 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2100 return false;
2101 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002102
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002103 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002104 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002105 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2106 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002107 return false;
2108 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002109
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002110 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002111 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2112 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002113 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002114
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002115 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002116 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002117 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002118 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2119 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002120 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002121
Douglas Gregor27887822010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002122 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2123 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2124 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2125 return true;
2126 }
2127
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002128 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002129}
2130
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002131bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2132 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2133 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002134
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002135 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002136 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2137 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002138
2139 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2140 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2141 return false;
2142
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002143 if (E->getBitField()) {
2144 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2145 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002146 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002147
2148 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2149 // bit-field.
2150 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002151 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002152 return false;
2153
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002154 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2155}
2156
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002157/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002158Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002159Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002160 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002161 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002162 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002163 return ExprError();
2164
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002165 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002166
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002167 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2168 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2169 return ExprError();
2170
2171 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002172 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002173 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2174 R.getEnd()));
2175}
2176
2177/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2178/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002179Action::OwningExprResult
2180Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002181 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2182 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2183 bool isInvalid = false;
2184 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2185 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2186 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2187 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002188 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002189 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2190 isInvalid = true;
2191 } else {
2192 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2193 }
2194
2195 if (isInvalid)
2196 return ExprError();
2197
2198 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2199 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2200 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2201 R.getEnd()));
2202}
2203
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002204/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2205/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2206/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002207Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002208Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2209 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002210 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002211 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002212
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002213 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002214 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2215 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2216 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002217 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002218
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002219 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2220 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2221 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2222
2223 if (Result.isInvalid())
2224 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2225
2226 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002227}
2228
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002229QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002230 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2231 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002232
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002233 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002234 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002235 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002236
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002237 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2238 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2239 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002240
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002241 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002242 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2243 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002244 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002245}
2246
2247
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002248
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002249Action::OwningExprResult
2250Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2251 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002252 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2253 switch (Kind) {
2254 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2255 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2256 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2257 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002258
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002259 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002260}
2261
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002262Action::OwningExprResult
2263Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2264 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002265 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2266 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2267
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002268 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2269 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002270
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002271 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002272 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2273 Base.release();
2274 Idx.release();
2275 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2276 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2277 }
2278
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002279 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002280 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002281 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2282 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2283 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002284 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002285 }
2286
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002287 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2288}
2289
2290
2291Action::OwningExprResult
2292Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2293 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2294 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2295 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2296
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002297 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002298 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2299 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2300 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002301
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002302 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002303
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002304 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002305 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002306 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002307 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002308 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2309 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002310 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2311 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2312 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2313 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002314 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002315 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2316 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002317 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002318 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002319 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002320 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2321 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002322 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002324 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002325 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2326 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2327 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002328 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002329 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002330 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2331 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2332 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2333 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002334 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002335 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002336 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002337
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002338 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2339 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002340 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2341 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002342 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002343 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2344 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2345 // force the promotion here.
2346 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2347 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002348 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2349 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002350 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2351
2352 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2353 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002354 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002355 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2356 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2357 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2358 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002359 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2360 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002361 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2362
2363 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2364 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002365 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002366 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002367 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2368 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002369 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002370 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002371 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002372 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2373 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002374
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002375 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002376 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2377 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002378 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2379
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002380 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002381 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2382 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002383 // incomplete types are not object types.
2384 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2385 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2386 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2387 return ExprError();
2388 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002389
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002390 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002391 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002392 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2393 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002394 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002395
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002396 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002397 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002398 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2399 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2400 return ExprError();
2401 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002402
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002403 Base.release();
2404 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002405 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002406 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002407}
2408
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002409QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002410CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002411 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002412 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002413 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2414 // see FIXME there.
2415 //
2416 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2417 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002418 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002419
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002420 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002421 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002422
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002423 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002424 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2425 // to be selected.
2426 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002427
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002428 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2429 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002430 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002431
2432 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2433 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002434 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002435 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2436 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002437 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002438 do
2439 compStr++;
2440 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002441 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002442 do
2443 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002444 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002445 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002446
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002447 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002448 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2449 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002450 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002451 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002452 return QualType();
2453 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002454
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002455 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2456 // operates on.
2457 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002458 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002459
2460 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002461 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002462
2463 while (*compStr) {
2464 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2465 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2466 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2467 return QualType();
2468 }
2469 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002470 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002471
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002472 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002473 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002474 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002475 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002476 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002477 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002478 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002479 if (HexSwizzle)
2480 CompSize--;
2481
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002482 if (CompSize == 1)
2483 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002484
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002485 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002486 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002487 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2488 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2489 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2490 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002491 }
2492 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002493}
2494
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002495static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002496 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002497 const Selector &Sel,
2498 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002499
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002500 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002501 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002502 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002503 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002504
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002505 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2506 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002507 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002508 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002509 return D;
2510 }
2511 return 0;
2512}
2513
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002514static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002515 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002516 const Selector &Sel,
2517 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002518 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2519 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002520 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002521 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002522 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002523 GDecl = PD;
2524 break;
2525 }
2526 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002527 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002528 GDecl = OMD;
2529 break;
2530 }
2531 }
2532 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002533 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002534 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2535 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002536 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002537 if (GDecl)
2538 return GDecl;
2539 }
2540 }
2541 return GDecl;
2542}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002543
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002544Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002545Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2546 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002547 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2548 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002549 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002550 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2551 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2552
2553 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2554 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2555 //
2556 // T* t;
2557 // t.f;
2558 //
2559 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2560 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2561 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2562 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002563 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002564 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2565 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002566 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002567 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002568 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002569 return ExprError();
2570 }
2571 }
2572
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002573 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2574 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002575 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002576
2577 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2578 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002579 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002580 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2581 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2582 SS.getRange(),
2583 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002584 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002585}
2586
2587/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2588/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2589/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2590static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2591 Expr *BaseExpr,
2592 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002593 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002594 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002595 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2596 // diagnostics.
2597 if (!BaseExpr)
2598 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002599
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002600 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2601 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002602}
2603
2604// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2605// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2606// type. The restriction here is:
2607//
2608// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2609// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2610// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2611//
2612// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2613// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2614// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2615// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2616bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2617 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002618 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002619 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002620 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2621 if (!BaseRT) {
2622 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2623 // dependent.
2624 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2625 return false;
2626 }
2627 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002628
2629 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002630 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2631 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002632 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002633 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002634
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002635 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002636 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2637 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2638 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002639
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002640 if (!DC->isRecord())
2641 continue;
2642
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002643 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002644 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002645
2646 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2647 return false;
2648 }
2649
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002650 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002651 return true;
2652}
2653
2654static bool
2655LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2656 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002657 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2658 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002659 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2660 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002661 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002662 << BaseRange))
2663 return true;
2664
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002665 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2666 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2667 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2668
2669 bool MOUS;
2670 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2671 return false;
2672 }
2673
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2675 if (SS.isSet()) {
2676 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2677 // nested-name-specifier.
2678 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2679
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002680 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002681 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2682 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2683 return true;
2684 }
2685
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002686 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002687
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2689 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2690 << DC << SS.getRange();
2691 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002692 }
2693 }
2694
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002695 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2696 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002698 if (!R.empty())
2699 return false;
2700
2701 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2702 // for typos.
2703 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002704 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002705 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002706 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2707 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2708 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002709 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2710 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002711 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2712 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2713 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002714 return false;
2715 } else {
2716 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002717 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002718 }
2719
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720 return false;
2721}
2722
2723Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002725 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002726 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002727 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002728 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002729 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2730 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2731
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002732 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2733 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002734 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002735 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2736 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002737 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002738
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002739 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002740
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002741 // Implicit member accesses.
2742 if (!Base) {
2743 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2744 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2745 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2746 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002747 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002748 return ExprError();
2749
2750 // Explicit member accesses.
2751 } else {
2752 OwningExprResult Result =
2753 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002754 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy(), TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755
2756 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2757 Owned(Base);
2758 return ExprError();
2759 }
2760
2761 if (Result.get())
2762 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002763
2764 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2765 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002766 }
2767
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002768 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002769 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2770 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002771}
2772
2773Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002774Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2775 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2776 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002777 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002779 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2780 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002781 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002783 if (IsArrow) {
2784 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2785 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2786 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002787 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788
2789 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2790 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002791 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2792 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2793 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002794
2795 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002796 return ExprError();
2797
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002798 if (R.empty()) {
2799 // Rederive where we looked up.
2800 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2801 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2802 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002803
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002804 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002805 << MemberName << DC
2806 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002807 return ExprError();
2808 }
2809
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002810 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2811 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2812 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2813 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2814 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2815 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2816 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2817 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2818 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2819 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002820 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002821 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002822 return ExprError();
2823
2824 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2825 // result.
2826 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002827 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002828 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002829 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002830 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002831
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002832 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2833 // pick a member.
2834 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2835
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2837 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2838 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002839 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2840 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002842 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002843 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002844
2845 return Owned(MemExpr);
2846 }
2847
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002848 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002849 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002850 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2851
2852 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2853
2854 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2855 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2856 // error cases.
2857 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2858 return ExprError();
2859
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002860 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2861 if (!BaseExpr) {
2862 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002863 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002864 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002865
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002866 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2867 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2868 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2869 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002870 }
2871
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2873 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2874 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2875 // explicitly qualified.
2876 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2877 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2878 }
2879
2880 // Check the use of this member.
2881 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2882 Owned(BaseExpr);
2883 return ExprError();
2884 }
2885
2886 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2887 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2888 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002889 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2890 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002891 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2892 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2893
2894 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2895 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2896 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2897 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2898 else {
2899 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2900 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2901 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2902
2903 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2904 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2905
2906 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2907 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2908 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2909 }
2910
2911 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002912 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002913 return ExprError();
2914 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002915 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2916 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002917 }
2918
2919 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2920 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2921 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002922 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2924 }
2925
2926 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2927 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2928 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002929 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002930 MemberFn->getType()));
2931 }
2932
2933 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2934 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2935 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002936 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2937 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002938 }
2939
2940 Owned(BaseExpr);
2941
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002942 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002943 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002944 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002945 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2946 else
2947 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2948 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002950 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2951 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002952 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002953 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002954}
2955
2956/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2957/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2958/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2959/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2960/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2961/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2962/// an ordinary member expression.
2963///
2964/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2965/// fixed for ObjC++.
2966Sema::OwningExprResult
2967Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002968 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002969 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002970 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002971 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002972
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002973 // Perform default conversions.
2974 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002975
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002976 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2978
2979 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2980 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002981
2982 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002983 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002984 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2985 // call, and continue on.
2986 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2987 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2988 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2989 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2990 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002991 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2992 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002993 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2994 ->isRecordType()))) {
2995 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2996 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2997 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002998 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002999
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003000 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003001 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003002 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003003 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003004 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003005 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003006
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003007 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3008 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3009 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3010 }
3011 }
3012 }
3013
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003014 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3015 // use that.
3016 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003017 if (IsArrow) {
3018 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3019 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3020 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003021 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003022 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003023 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3024 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003025 }
3026 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003027 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3028 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3029 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3030 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003031 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003032 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003033 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003034
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003035 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3036 // use that.
3037 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3038 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3039 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3040 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3041 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
3042 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
3043 }
3044 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003046 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003047
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003048 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003049 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003050 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3051 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3052 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3053 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3054 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3055 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3056 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3057 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3058 // Check the use of this method.
3059 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3060 return ExprError();
3061 }
3062 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3063 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3064 Selector SetterSel =
3065 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3066 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3067 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3068 if (!Setter) {
3069 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3070 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003071 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003072 }
3073 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3074 if (!Setter)
3075 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003076
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003077 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3078 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003079
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003080 if (Getter || Setter) {
3081 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003082
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003083 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003084 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003085 else
3086 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3087 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3088 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003089 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003090 PType,
3091 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3092 }
3093 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3094 << MemberName << BaseType);
3095 }
3096 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003097
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003098 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3099 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3100 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003101 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003102 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003103
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003104 if (IsArrow) {
3105 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003106 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003107 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3108 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003109 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3110 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3111 // struct MyRecord foo;
3112 // foo->bar
3113 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3114 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3115 // by now.
3116 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3117 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003118 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003119 IsArrow = false;
3120 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003121 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3122 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3123 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003124 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003125 } else {
3126 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3127 // type *foo;
3128 // foo.bar
3129 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3130 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3131 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3132 // the appropriate pointer type
3133 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3134 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3135 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3136 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3137 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003138 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003139 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3140 IsArrow = true;
3141 }
3142 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003143 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003144
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003145 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003146 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003147 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003148 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003149 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003150 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003151 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003152
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003153 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3154 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003155 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003156 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003157 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003158 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3159 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3160 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3161 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003162 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3163
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003164 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003165 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003166
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003167 if (!IV) {
3168 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3169 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3170 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003171 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003172 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003173 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003174 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3175 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003176 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3177 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003178 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003179 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003180 } else {
3181 Res.clear();
3182 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003183 }
3184 }
3185
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003186 if (IV) {
3187 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3188 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3189 // error cases.
3190 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3191 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003192
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003193 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3194 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3195 return ExprError();
3196 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3197 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3198 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3199 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3200 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3201 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3202 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3203 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3204 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3205 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3206 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3207 // AST for a function decl.
3208 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003209 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003210 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3211 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3212 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3213 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3214 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3215 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003216
3217 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3218 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003219 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003220 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003221 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003222 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3223 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003224 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003225 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003226 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003227
3228 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3229 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003230 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003231 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003232 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003233 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003234 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003235 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003236 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003237 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003238 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3239 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003240 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003241 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003242
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003243 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003244 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003245 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3246 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3247 // Check the use of this declaration
3248 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3249 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003251 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3252 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3253 }
3254 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3255 // Check the use of this method.
3256 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3257 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003258
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003259 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003260 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003261 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3262 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003263 }
3264 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003265
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003266 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003267 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003268 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003269
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003270 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3271 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003272 if (!IsArrow)
3273 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3274 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003275 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003276
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003277 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003278 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003279 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3280 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003281 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003282 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003283 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003284
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003285 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003286 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003287 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003288 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3289 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003290 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003291 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003292 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003293 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003294
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003295 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3296 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3297
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003298 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003299}
3300
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003301/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3302/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3303/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3304/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3305/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3306///
3307/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3308/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3309/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3310/// only be called
3311/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3312/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3313/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3314Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3315 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3316 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003317 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003318 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3319 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3320 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3321 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3322 return ExprError();
3323
3324 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3325
3326 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003327 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003328 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3329 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003330 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003331
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003332 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003333 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3334
3335 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3336 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3337 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3338
3339 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3340 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3341
3342 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3343 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003344 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3345 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003346 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003347 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3348 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003349 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003351 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003352 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3353 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003354
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003355 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3356 Owned(Base);
3357 return ExprError();
3358 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003359
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003360 if (Result.get()) {
3361 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3362 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3363 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3364 // call now.
3365 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3366 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003367 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003368
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003369 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003370 }
3371
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003372 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003373 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3374 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 }
3376
3377 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003378}
3379
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003380Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3381 FunctionDecl *FD,
3382 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3383 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3384 Diag (CallLoc,
3385 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3386 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003387 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003388 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3389 } else {
3390 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3391 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3392
3393 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003394 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3395 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003396
Douglas Gregor9961ce92010-07-08 18:37:38 +00003397 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3398 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3399 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3400 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003401
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003402 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003403 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003404 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003405
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003406 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3407 InitializedEntity Entity
3408 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3409 InitializationKind Kind
3410 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3411 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3412 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3413
3414 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003415 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003416 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3417 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003418 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003419
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003420 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003421 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003422 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003423 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003424
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003425 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3426 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3427 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003428 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3429 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003430 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3431 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003432 }
3433
3434 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003435 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003436}
3437
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003438/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3439/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3440/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3441/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3442/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3443/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003444bool
3445Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003446 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003447 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003448 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3449 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003450 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003451 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3452 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003453 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003454
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003455 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3456 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3457 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3458 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3459 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003460 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003461 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003462 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003463 }
3464
3465 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3466 // them.
3467 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3468 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3469 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3470 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003471 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003472 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003473 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3474 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3475 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003476 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003477 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003479 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003480 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003481 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003482 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3483 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3484 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3485 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3486 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003487 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003488 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003489 if (Invalid)
3490 return true;
3491 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3492 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3493 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003494
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003495 return false;
3496}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003497
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003498bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3499 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3500 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3501 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3502 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3503 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003504 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003505 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3506 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3507 bool Invalid = false;
3508 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3509 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3510 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3511 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003512 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003513 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003514 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003515
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003516 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003517 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3518 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003519
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003520 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3521 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003522 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003523 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003524 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003525
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003526 // Pass the argument
3527 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3528 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3529 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003530
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003531
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003532 InitializedEntity Entity =
3533 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3534 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3535 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3536 SourceLocation(),
3537 Owned(Arg));
3538 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3539 return true;
3540
3541 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003542 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003543 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003544
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003545 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003546 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003547 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3548 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003549
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003550 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003551 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003552 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003553 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003554
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003555 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003556 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003557 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003558 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003559 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003560 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003561 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003562 }
3563 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003564 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003565}
3566
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003567/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003568/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3569/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003570Action::OwningExprResult
3571Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3572 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003573 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003574 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003575
3576 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3577 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003578
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003579 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003580 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003581 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003582
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003583 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003584 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3585 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3586 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3587 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3588 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003589 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003590 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3591 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003592
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003593 NumArgs = 0;
3594 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003595
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003596 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3597 RParenLoc));
3598 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003599
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003600 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003601 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003602 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3603 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003604 bool Dependent = false;
3605 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3606 Dependent = true;
3607 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3608 Dependent = true;
3609
3610 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003611 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003612 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3613
3614 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3615 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3616 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3617 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3618
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003619 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3620
3621 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3622 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3623 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3624 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3625 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3626 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3627 // method template.
3628 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003629 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3630 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003631 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003632
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003633 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3634 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003635 }
3636
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003637 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003638 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003639 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003640 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003641 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3642 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003643 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003644
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003645 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003646 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003647 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3648 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003649 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3650 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003651 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003652
3653 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3654 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003655 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3656 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003657
3658 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3659 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003660 TheCall.get(), 0))
3661 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003662
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003663 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003664 RParenLoc))
3665 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003666
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003667 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3668 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003669 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003670 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3671 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003672 }
3673 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003674 }
3675
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003676 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003677 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003678 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003679
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003680 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003681 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3682 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003683 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003684 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003685 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003686
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003687 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3688 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3689 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3690
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003691 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3692}
3693
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003694/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3695/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003696/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3697/// block-pointer type.
3698///
3699/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3700Sema::OwningExprResult
3701Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3702 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3703 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3704 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3705 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3706
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003707 // Promote the function operand.
3708 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3709
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003710 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3711 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003712 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3713 Args, NumArgs,
3714 Context.BoolTy,
3715 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003716
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003717 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3718 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3719 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3720 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003721 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003722 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003723 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3724 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003725 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003726 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003727 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003728 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003729 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003730 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003731 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3732 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3733
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003734 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003735 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003736 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3737 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003738 return ExprError();
3739
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003740 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003741 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003742
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003743 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003744 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003745 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003746 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003747 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003748 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003749
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003750 if (FDecl) {
3751 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3752 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3753 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003754 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003755 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003756 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003757 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3758 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3759 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3760 }
3761 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003762 }
3763
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003764 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003765 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3766 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3767 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003768 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3769 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003770 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3771 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003772 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003773 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003774 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003775 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003776
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003777 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3778 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003779 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3780 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003781
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003782 // Check for sentinels
3783 if (NDecl)
3784 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003785
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003786 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003787 if (FDecl) {
3788 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3789 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003790
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003791 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003792 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3793 } else if (NDecl) {
3794 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3795 return ExprError();
3796 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003797
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003798 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003799}
3800
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003801Action::OwningExprResult
3802Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3803 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003804 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003805 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003806 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003807
3808 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3809 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3810 if (!TInfo)
3811 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3812
3813 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3814}
3815
3816Action::OwningExprResult
3817Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3818 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3819 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003820 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003821
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003822 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003823 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003824 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3825 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003826 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3827 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003828 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003829 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003830 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003831 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003832
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003833 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003834 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003835 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003836 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003837 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003838 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3839 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3840 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3841 &literalType);
3842 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003843 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003844 InitExpr.release();
3845 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003846
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003847 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003848 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003849 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003850 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003851 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003852
3853 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003854
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003855 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003856 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003857}
3858
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003859Action::OwningExprResult
3860Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003861 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3862 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3863 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003864
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003865 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003866 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003867
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003868 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3869 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003870 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003871 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003872}
3873
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003874static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3875 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003876 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003877 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3878
3879 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3880 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003881 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3882 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003883 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003884 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3885 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3886 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003887
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003888 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3889 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3890 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3891 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3892 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3893 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3894 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3895 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003896
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003897 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3898 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3899 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3900 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3901 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3902 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003903
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003904 // FIXME: Assert here.
3905 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3906 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3907}
3908
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003909/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003910bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003911 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003912 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003913 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003914 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003915 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3916 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003917
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003918 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003919
3920 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3921 // type needs to be scalar.
3922 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3923 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003924 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3925 return false;
3926 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003927
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003928 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3929 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3930 return true;
3931
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003932 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003933 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003934 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3935 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003936 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003937 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3938 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003939 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003940 return false;
3941 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003942
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003943 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003944 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003945 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003946 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003947 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003948 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003949 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003950 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003951 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3952 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3953 break;
3954 }
3955 }
3956 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3957 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3958 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003959 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003960 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003961 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003962
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003963 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3964 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3965 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3966 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003967
3968 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003969 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003970 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3971 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003972 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003973 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003974
3975 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003976 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003977
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003978 if (castType->isVectorType())
3979 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3980 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3981 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3982
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003983 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3984 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003985
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003986 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003987 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003988 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00003989 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003990 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3991 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3992 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3993 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00003994 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003995 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3996 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3997 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003998 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003999
4000 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004001
4002 if (Kind == CastExpr::CK_Unknown || Kind == CastExpr::CK_BitCast)
4003 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4004
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004005 return false;
4006}
4007
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004008bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
4009 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004010 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004011
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004012 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004013 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004014 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004015 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004016 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004017 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004018 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004019 } else
4020 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004021 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004022 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004023
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004024 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004025 return false;
4026}
4027
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004028bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004029 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004030 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004031
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004032 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004033
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004034 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4035 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004036 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4037 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4038 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4039 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004040 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004041 return false;
4042 }
4043
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004044 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004045 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4046 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004047 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4048 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4049 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4050 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004051
4052 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4053 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4054 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004055
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004056 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004057 return false;
4058}
4059
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004060Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004061Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004062 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4063 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
4064 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004065
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004066 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4067 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4068 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004069 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004070
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004071 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004072 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004073 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004074 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4075 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004076
4077 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4078}
4079
4080Action::OwningExprResult
4081Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4082 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4083 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4084
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004085 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004086 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004087 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004088 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004089 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004090
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004091 Op.release();
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004092 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004093 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004094 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4095 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004096}
4097
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004098/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4099/// of comma binary operators.
4100Action::OwningExprResult
4101Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4102 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4103 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4104 if (!E)
4105 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004106
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004107 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004108
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004109 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4110 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4111 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004112
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4114}
4115
4116Action::OwningExprResult
4117Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4118 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004119 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004120 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004121 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004122 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004123
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004124 // Check for an altivec literal,
4125 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004126 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4127 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4128 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4129 return ExprError();
4130 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004131 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4132 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4133 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4134 }
4135 else
4136 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4137 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004138
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004139 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4140 // then handle it as such.
4141 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004142 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4143 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4144 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4145
4146 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4147 // braces instead of the original commas.
4148 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004149 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4150 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004151 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4152 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004153 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004155 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004156 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4157 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004158 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004159 }
4160}
4161
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004162Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004163 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004164 MultiExprArg Val,
4165 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004166 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4167 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004168 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4169 Expr *expr;
4170 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4171 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4172 else
4173 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004174 return Owned(expr);
4175}
4176
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004177/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4178/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004179/// C99 6.5.15
4180QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4181 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004182 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4183 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4184 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4185
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004186 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4187 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4188 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4189 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4190 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4191 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004192
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004193 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004194 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4195 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4196 << CondTy;
4197 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004198 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004199
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004200 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004201 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4202 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004203
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004204 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4205 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004206 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4207 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4208 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004209 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004210
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004211 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4212 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004213 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4214 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004215 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004216 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004217 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004218 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004219 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004220 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004221
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004222 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004223 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004224 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4225 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4226 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4227 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4228 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4229 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4230 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004231 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4232 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004233 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004234 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004235 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4236 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004237 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004238 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004239 // promote the null to a pointer.
4240 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004241 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004242 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004243 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004244 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004245 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004246 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004247 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004248
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004249 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4250 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4251 QuestionLoc);
4252 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4253 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004254
4255
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004256 // Handle block pointer types.
4257 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4258 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4259 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4260 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004261 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4262 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004263 return destType;
4264 }
4265 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004266 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004267 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004268 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004269 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4270 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4271 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004272 return LHSTy;
4273 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004274 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004275 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4276 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004277
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004278 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4279 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004280 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004281 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004282 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4283 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4284 // to get a consistent AST.
4285 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004286 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4287 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004288 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004289 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004290 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004291 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4292 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004293 return LHSTy;
4294 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004295
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004296 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4297 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4298 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004299 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4300 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004301
4302 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4303 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4304 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004305 QualType destPointee
4306 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004307 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004308 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4309 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4310 // Promote to void*.
4311 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004312 return destType;
4313 }
4314 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004315 QualType destPointee
4316 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004317 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004318 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004319 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004320 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004321 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004322 return destType;
4323 }
4324
4325 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4326 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4327 return LHSTy;
4328 }
4329 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4330 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4331 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4332 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4333 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4334 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4335 // to get a consistent AST.
4336 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004337 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4338 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004339 return incompatTy;
4340 }
4341 // The pointer types are compatible.
4342 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4343 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4344 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4345 // type.
4346 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4347 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004348 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4349 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004350 return LHSTy;
4351 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004352
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004353 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4354 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4355 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4356 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004357 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004358 return RHSTy;
4359 }
4360 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4361 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4362 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004363 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004364 return LHSTy;
4365 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004366
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004367 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004368 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4369 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004370 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004371}
4372
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004373/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4374/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4375QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4376 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4377 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4378 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004379
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004380 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4381 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4382 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4383 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4384 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4385 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4386 return LHSTy;
4387 }
4388 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4389 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4390 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4391 return RHSTy;
4392 }
4393 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4394 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4395 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4396 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4397 return LHSTy;
4398 }
4399 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4400 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4401 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4402 return RHSTy;
4403 }
4404 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4405 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4406 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4407 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4408 return LHSTy;
4409 }
4410 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4411 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4412 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4413 return RHSTy;
4414 }
4415 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4416 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004417
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004418 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4419 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4420 return LHSTy;
4421 }
4422 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4423 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4424 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004425
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004426 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4427 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4428 // type. This allows
4429 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4430 // where B is a subclass of A.
4431 //
4432 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4433 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4434 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4435 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004436
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004437 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4438 // It could return the composite type.
4439 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4440 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4441 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4442 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4443 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4444 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4445 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4446 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4447 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4448 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4449 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4450 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4451 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4452 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004453 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004454 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4455 ;
4456 else {
4457 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4458 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4459 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4460 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4461 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4462 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4463 return incompatTy;
4464 }
4465 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4466 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4467 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4468 return compositeType;
4469 }
4470 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4471 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4472 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4473 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4474 QualType destPointee
4475 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4476 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4477 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4478 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4479 // Promote to void*.
4480 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4481 return destType;
4482 }
4483 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4484 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4485 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4486 QualType destPointee
4487 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4488 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4489 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4490 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4491 // Promote to void*.
4492 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4493 return destType;
4494 }
4495 return QualType();
4496}
4497
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004498/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004499/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004500Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4501 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4502 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4503 ExprArg RHS) {
4504 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4505 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004506
4507 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4508 // was the condition.
4509 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4510 if (isLHSNull)
4511 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004512
4513 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004514 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004515 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004516 return ExprError();
4517
4518 Cond.release();
4519 LHS.release();
4520 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004521 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004522 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004523 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004524}
4525
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004526// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004527// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004528// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4529// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4530// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004531Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004532Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004533 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004534
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004535 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4536 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4537 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4538 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4539 return Compatible;
4540 }
4541
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004542 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004543 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4544 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004545
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004546 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004547 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4548 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004549
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004550 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004551
4552 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4553 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4554 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004555 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004556 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004557 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004558
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004559 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4560 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004561 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004562 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004563 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004564 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004565
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004566 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004567 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4568 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004569 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004570
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004571 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004572 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004573 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004574
4575 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004576 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4577 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004578 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004579 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004580 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004581 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4582 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4583 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4584 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4585 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4586 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004587 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004588 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004589 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004590 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004591
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004592 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004593 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004594 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004595 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004596
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004597 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4598 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4599 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4600 // warning can be disabled.
4601 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4602 return ConvTy;
4603 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4604 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004606 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4607 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4608 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4609 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4610 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4611 do {
4612 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4613 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004614
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004615 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4616 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4617 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004618
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004619 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004620 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004621 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004622
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004623 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004624 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004625 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004626 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004627}
4628
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004629/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4630/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4631/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4632// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004633Sema::AssignConvertType
4634Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004635 QualType rhsType) {
4636 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004637
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004638 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004639 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4640 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004641
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004642 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4643 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4644 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004645
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004646 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004647
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004648 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004649 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004650 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004651
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004652 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4653 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4654 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4655 }
4656 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004657 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004658 return ConvTy;
4659}
4660
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004661/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4662/// for assignment compatibility.
4663Sema::AssignConvertType
4664Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004665 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4666 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004667 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4668 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004669 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004670 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004671 }
4672 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4673 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004674 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4675 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004676 return IncompatiblePointer;
4677 return Compatible;
4678 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004679 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004680 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004681 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004682 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4683 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4684 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4685 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4686 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4687 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004688
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004689 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4690 return Compatible;
4691 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4692 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004693 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004694}
4695
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004696/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4697/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004698/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4699///
4700/// int a, *pint;
4701/// short *pshort;
4702/// struct foo *pfoo;
4703///
4704/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4705/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4706/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4707/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4708///
4709/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004710/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004711///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004712Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004713Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004714 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4715 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004716 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4717 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004718
4719 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004720 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004721
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004722 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4723 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4724 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4725 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4726 return Compatible;
4727 }
4728
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004729 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4730 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4731 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4732 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4733 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4734 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4735 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004736 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004737 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004738 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004739 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004740 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004741 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4742 // to the same ExtVector type.
4743 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4744 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4745 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004746 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004747 return Compatible;
4748 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004749
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004750 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004751 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4752 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4753 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4754 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4755 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4756 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004757 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004758
4759 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4760 // vector type and vice versa
4761 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4762 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004763 }
4764 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004765 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004766
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004767 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4768 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004769 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004770
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004771 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004772 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004773 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004774
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004775 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004776 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004777
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004778 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004779 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004780 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4781 return Compatible;
4782 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004783 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004784 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4785 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004786 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004787
4788 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004789 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004790 return Compatible;
4791 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004792 return Incompatible;
4793 }
4794
4795 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4796 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004797 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004798
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004799 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004800 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004801 return Compatible;
4802
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004803 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4804 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004805
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004806 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004807 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004808 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004809 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004810 return Incompatible;
4811 }
4812
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004813 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4814 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4815 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004816
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004817 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004818 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004819 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4820 return Compatible;
4821 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004822 }
4823 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004824 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004825 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004826 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004827 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4828 return Compatible;
4829 }
4830 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4831 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4832 return Compatible;
4833 return Incompatible;
4834 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004835 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004836 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004837 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4838 return Compatible;
4839
4840 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004841 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004842
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004843 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004844 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004845
4846 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004847 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004848 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004849 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004850 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004851 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4852 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4853 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4854 return Compatible;
4855
4856 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4857 return PointerToInt;
4858
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004859 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004860 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004861 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4862 return Compatible;
4863 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004864 }
4865 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004866 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004867 return Compatible;
4868 return Incompatible;
4869 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004870
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004871 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004872 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004873 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004874 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004875 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004876}
4877
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004878/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4879/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004880static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004881 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4882 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4883 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004884 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004885 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004886 SourceLocation());
4887 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4888 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4889
4890 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4891 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004892 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004893 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004894 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004895}
4896
4897Sema::AssignConvertType
4898Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4899 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4900
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004901 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004902 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4903 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004904 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004905 return Incompatible;
4906
4907 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4908 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4909 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4910 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004911 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4912 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004913 it != itend; ++it) {
4914 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4915 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4916 // 1) void pointer
4917 // 2) null pointer constant
4918 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004919 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004920 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004921 InitField = *it;
4922 break;
4923 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004924
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004925 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004926 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004927 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004928 InitField = *it;
4929 break;
4930 }
4931 }
4932
4933 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4934 == Compatible) {
4935 InitField = *it;
4936 break;
4937 }
4938 }
4939
4940 if (!InitField)
4941 return Incompatible;
4942
4943 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4944 return Compatible;
4945}
4946
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004947Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004948Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004949 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4950 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4951 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4952 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4953 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004954 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004955 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004956 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004957 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004958 }
4959
4960 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4961 // structures.
4962 }
4963
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004964 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4965 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004966 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4967 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004968 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004969 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004970 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004971 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004972 return Compatible;
4973 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004974
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004975 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004976 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004977 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00004978 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004979 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004980 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004981 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004982 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004983
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004984 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4985 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004986
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004987 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4988 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004989 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4990 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4991 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4992 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004993 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004994 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004995 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004996 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004997}
4998
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004999QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005000 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005001 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005002 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005003 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005004}
5005
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005006QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005007 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005008 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005009 QualType lhsType =
5010 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5011 QualType rhsType =
5012 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005013
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005014 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005015 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005016 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005017
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005018 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5019 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005020 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
5021 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005022 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5023 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005024 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005025 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005026 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5027 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5028 return lhsType;
5029 }
5030
5031 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5032 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005033 }
5034 }
5035 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005036
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005037 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5038 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5039 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
5040 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5041 return rhsType;
5042 }
5043
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005044 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5045 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5046 bool swapped = false;
5047 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5048 swapped = true;
5049 std::swap(rex, lex);
5050 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5051 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005052
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005053 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005054 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005055 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005056 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005057 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005058 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005059 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5060 return lhsType;
5061 }
5062 }
5063 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5064 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5065 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005066 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005067 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5068 return lhsType;
5069 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005070 }
5071 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005072
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005073 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005074 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005075 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005076 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005077 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005078}
5079
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005080QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5081 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005082 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005083 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005084
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005085 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005086
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005087 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5088 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5089 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005090
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005091 // Check for division by zero.
5092 if (isDiv &&
5093 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005094 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005095 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005096
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005097 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005098}
5099
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005100QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005101 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005102 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005103 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5104 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005105 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5106 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5107 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005108
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005109 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005110
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005111 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5112 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005113
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005114 // Check for remainder by zero.
5115 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005116 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5117 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005118
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005119 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005120}
5121
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005122QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005123 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005124 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5125 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5126 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5127 return compType;
5128 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005129
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005130 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005131
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005132 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005133 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5134 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5135 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005136 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005137 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005138
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005139 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5140 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005141 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005142 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5143
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005144 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005145
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005146 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005147 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005148
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005149 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5150 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005151 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5152 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005153 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005154 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005155 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005156
5157 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5158 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5159 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005160 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005161 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5163 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5164 return QualType();
5165 }
5166
5167 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5168 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5169 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005170 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005171 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005172 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005173 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005174 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5175 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005176 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5177 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005178 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005179 return QualType();
5180 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005181 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005182 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005183 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5184 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5185 return QualType();
5186 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005187
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005188 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005189 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5190 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5191 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5192 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5193 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005194 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005195 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5196 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005197 return PExp->getType();
5198 }
5199 }
5200
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005201 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005202}
5203
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005204// C99 6.5.6
5205QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005206 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5207 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5208 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5209 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5210 return compType;
5211 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005212
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005213 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005214
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005215 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005216
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005217 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005218 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5219 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005220 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005221 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005222 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005223
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005224 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005225 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005226 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005227
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005228 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005229
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005230 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5231 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5232 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5233 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5234 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5235 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5236 return QualType();
5237 }
5238
5239 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5240 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5241 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5242 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5243 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005244 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005245 return QualType();
5246 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005247
5248 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5249 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5250 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005251 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005252 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005253 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005254 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005255 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005256
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005257 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005258 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005259 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5260 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5261 return QualType();
5262 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005263
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005264 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005265 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5266 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5267 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5268 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5269 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5270 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005271 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005272 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5273
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005274 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005275 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005276 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005277
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005278 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005279 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005280 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005281
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005282 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5283 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5284 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5285 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5286 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5287 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5288 return QualType();
5289 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005290
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005291 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5292 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5293 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5294 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005295 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005296 return QualType();
5297 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005298
5299 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5300 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5301 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5302 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5303 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005304 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5305 << rex->getSourceRange()
5306 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005307 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005308
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005309 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5310 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5311 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5312 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5313 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5314 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5315 return QualType();
5316 }
5317 } else {
5318 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5319 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5320 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5321 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5322 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5323 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5324 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5325 return QualType();
5326 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005327 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005328
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005329 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5330 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5331 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5332 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5333 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005334 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005335 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005336
5337 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005338 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5339 }
5340 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005341
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005342 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005343}
5344
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005345// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005346QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005347 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005348 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005349 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5350 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005351 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005352
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005353 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5354 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5355 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5356
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005357 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5358 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005359 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5360 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5361 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5362 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5363 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005364 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005365 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005366 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005367
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005368 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005370 // Sanity-check shift operands
5371 llvm::APSInt Right;
5372 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005373 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5374 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005375 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005376 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5377 else {
5378 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5379 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5380 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5381 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5382 }
5383 }
5384
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005385 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005386 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005387}
5388
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005389static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5390 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5391 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5392 return true;
5393 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5394 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5395 }
5396 return false;
5397}
5398
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005399// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005400QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005401 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5402 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5403
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005404 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005405 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005406 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005407
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005408 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5409 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005410
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005411 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
5412 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005413 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5414 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5415 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005416 //
5417 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5418 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5419 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5420 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5421 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5422 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005423 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5424 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005425 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005426 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005427 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() && !Loc.isMacroID() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005428 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005429 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5430 << 0 // self-
5431 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::EQ
5432 || Opc == BinaryOperator::LE
5433 || Opc == BinaryOperator::GE));
5434 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5435 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5436 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5437 // what is it always going to eval to?
5438 char always_evals_to;
5439 switch(Opc) {
5440 case BinaryOperator::EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
5441 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5442 break;
5443 case BinaryOperator::NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
5444 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5445 break;
5446 default:
5447 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5448 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5449 break;
5450 }
5451 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5452 << 1 // array
5453 << always_evals_to);
5454 }
5455 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005458 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5459 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5460 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5461 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005462
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005463 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5464 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005465 Expr *literalString = 0;
5466 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005467 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005468 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005469 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005470 literalString = lex;
5471 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005472 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5473 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005474 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005475 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005476 literalString = rex;
5477 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5478 }
5479
5480 if (literalString) {
5481 std::string resultComparison;
5482 switch (Opc) {
5483 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5484 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5485 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5486 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5487 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5488 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5489 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5490 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005491
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005492 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5493 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5494 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005495 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005496 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005497 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005498
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005499 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5500 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5501 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5502 else {
5503 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5504 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5505 }
5506
5507 lType = lex->getType();
5508 rType = rex->getType();
5509
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005510 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005511 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005512
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005513 if (isRelational) {
5514 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005515 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005516 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005517 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005518 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005519 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005520
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005521 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005522 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005523 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005524
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005525 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005526 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005527 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005528 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005529
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005530 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5531 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005532 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005533 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005534 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005535 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005536 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005537
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005538 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005539 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5540 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005541 if (!isRelational &&
5542 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5543 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5544 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005545 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5546 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005547 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5548 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005549 Diag(Loc,
5550 isSFINAEContext()?
5551 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5552 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005553 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005554
5555 if (isSFINAEContext())
5556 return QualType();
5557
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005558 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5559 return ResultTy;
5560 }
5561 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005562 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5563 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5564 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5565 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5566 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5567 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005568 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005569 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005570 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005571 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005572 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005573 if (T.isNull()) {
5574 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5575 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5576 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005577 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005578 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005579 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005580 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005581 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005582 }
5583
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005584 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5585 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005586 return ResultTy;
5587 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005588 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5589 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5590 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5591 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5592 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5593 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5594 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5595 }
5596 } else if (!isRelational &&
5597 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5598 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5599 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5600 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5601 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5602 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5603 }
5604 } else {
5605 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005606 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005607 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005608 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005609 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005610 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005611 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005612 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005613
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005614 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005615 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005616 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005617 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005618 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5619 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005620 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5621 lType->isMemberPointerType()
5622 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5623 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005624 return ResultTy;
5625 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005626 if (LHSIsNull &&
5627 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5628 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005629 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5630 rType->isMemberPointerType()
5631 ? CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer
5632 : CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005633 return ResultTy;
5634 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005635
5636 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005637 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005638 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5639 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005640 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5641 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5642 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5643 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5644 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5645 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5646 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5647 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005648 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005649 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005650 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005651 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005652 if (T.isNull()) {
5653 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005654 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005655 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005656 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005657 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005658 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005659 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005660 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005661 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005662
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005663 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5664 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005665 return ResultTy;
5666 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005667
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005668 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005669 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5670 return ResultTy;
5671 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005672
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005673 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005674 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005675 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5676 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005677
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005678 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005679 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005680 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005681 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005682 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005683 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005684 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005685 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005686 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005687 if (!isRelational
5688 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5689 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005690 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005691 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005692 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005693 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005694 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5695 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5696 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005697 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005698 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005699 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005700 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005701
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005702 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005703 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005704 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5705 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005706 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005707 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005708 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005709 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005710
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005711 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5712 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005713 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005714 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005715 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005716 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005717 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005718 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005719 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005720 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005721 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5722 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005723 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005724 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005725 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005726 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005727 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5728 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005729 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005730 bool isError = false;
5731 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5732 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5733 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005734 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005735 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005736 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005737 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5738 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5739 isError = true;
5740 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005741 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005742
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005743 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005744 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005745 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005746 if (isError)
5747 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005748 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005749
5750 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5751 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005752 else
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005753 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005754 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005755 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005756
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005757 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005758 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5759 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005760 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005761 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005762 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005763 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5764 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005765 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005766 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005767 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005768 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005769}
5770
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005771/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005772/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005773/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5774/// types.
5775QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005776 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005777 bool isRelational) {
5778 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5779 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005780 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005781 if (vType.isNull())
5782 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005783
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005784 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5785 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005786
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005787 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5788 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5789 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005790 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005791 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5792 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5793 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005794 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5795 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5796 << 0 // self-
5797 << 2 // "a constant"
5798 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005799 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005800
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005801 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005802 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5803 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005804 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005805 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005806
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005807 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5808 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5809 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005810 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005811 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005812
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005813 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005814 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005815 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005816 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005817 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005818 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5819
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005820 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005821 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005822 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5823}
5824
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005825inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005826 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005827 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5828 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5829 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5830 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5831
5832 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5833 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005834
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005835 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005836
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005837 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005838 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005839 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005840}
5841
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005842inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005843 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5844
5845 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5846 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5847 // is a constant.
5848 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005849 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005850 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005851 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5852 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5853 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5854 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5855 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5856 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5857 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5858 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5859 << rex->getSourceRange()
5860 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5861 << (Opc == BinaryOperator::LAnd ? "&" : "|");
5862 }
5863 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005864
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005865 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5866 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5867 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005868
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005869 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5870 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005871
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005872 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005873 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005874
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005875 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5876 // non-overloadable operands.
5877
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005878 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5879 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005880 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5881 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5882 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005883 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005884
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005885 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5886 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5887 // The result is a bool.
5888 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005889}
5890
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005891/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5892/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5893/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5894///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005895static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005896 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5897 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5898 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5899 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005900 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005901 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5902 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5903 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5904 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005905 }
5906 }
5907 return false;
5908}
5909
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005910/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5911/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5912static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005913 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005914 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005915 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005916 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5917 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005918 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5919 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005920
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005921 unsigned Diag = 0;
5922 bool NeedType = false;
5923 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005924 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005925 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005926 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5927 NeedType = true;
5928 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005929 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005930 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5931 NeedType = true;
5932 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005933 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005934 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5935 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005936 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5937 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005938 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005939 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5940 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005941 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5942 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005943 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5944 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005945 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005946 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005947 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005948 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005949 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5950 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005951 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005952 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5953 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005954 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5955 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5956 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005957 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5958 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5959 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005960 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5961 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5962 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005963 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005964
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005965 SourceRange Assign;
5966 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5967 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005968 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005969 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005970 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005971 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005972 return true;
5973}
5974
5975
5976
5977// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005978QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5979 SourceLocation Loc,
5980 QualType CompoundType) {
5981 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5982 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005983 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005984
5985 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5986 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005987 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005988 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005989 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005990 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005991 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5992 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5993 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5994 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5995 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5996 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5997 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5998 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5999 }
6000 }
6001
6002 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006003 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6004 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6005 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006006 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006007 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006008 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006009 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006010
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006011 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6012 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6013 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006014 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006015 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6016 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6017 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
6018 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
6019 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006020 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006021 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006022 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6023 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6024 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006025 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6026 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006027 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
6028 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
6029 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006030 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006031 }
6032 } else {
6033 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006034 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006035 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006036
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006037 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006038 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006039 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006040
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006041
6042 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6043 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6044 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6045 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6046 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6047 // check.
6048 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
6049 if (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref &&
6050 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6051 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6052 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6053 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6054 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6055 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6056 }
6057
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006058 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6059 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006060 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006061 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6062 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006063 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006064 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006065 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006066}
6067
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006068// C99 6.5.17
6069QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006070 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6071
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006072 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006073 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6074 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6075 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006076
6077 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6078 // incomplete in C++).
6079
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006080 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006081}
6082
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006083/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6084/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006085QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006086 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006087 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6088 return Context.DependentTy;
6089
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006090 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6091 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006092
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006093 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6094 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6095 if (!isInc) {
6096 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6097 return QualType();
6098 }
6099 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6100 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6101 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006102 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006103 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6104 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006105
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006106 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006107 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006108 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6109 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6110 << Op->getSourceRange();
6111 return QualType();
6112 }
6113
6114 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006115 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006116 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006117 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6119 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6120 return QualType();
6121 }
6122
6123 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006124 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006125 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006126 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006127 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006128 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006129 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006130 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006131 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006132 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6133 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6134 return QualType();
6135 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006136 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006137 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6138 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006139 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006140 } else {
6141 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006142 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006143 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006144 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006145 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006146 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006147 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006148 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006149 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6150 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6151 // operand.
6152 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6153 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006154}
6155
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006156/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006157/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006158/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6159/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6160/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6161/// - &(x) => x
6162/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6163/// - &s.xx => s
6164/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6165/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6166/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6167/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006168static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006169 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006170 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006171 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006172 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006173 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6174 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6175 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006176 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006177 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006178 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006179 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006180 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006181 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6182 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006183 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6184 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6185 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6186 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6187 }
6188 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006189 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006190 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6191 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006192
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006193 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006194 case UnaryOperator::Real:
6195 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
6196 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
6197 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6198 default:
6199 return 0;
6200 }
6201 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006202 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006203 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006204 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006205 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6206 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006207 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006208 default:
6209 return 0;
6210 }
6211}
6212
6213/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006214/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006215/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006216/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006217/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006218/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006219/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006220QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006221 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6222 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6223
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006224 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6225 return Context.DependentTy;
6226
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006227 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6228 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6229 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6230 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6231 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6232 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6233 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6234 }
6235 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6236 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6237 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006238 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006239 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006240
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006241 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6242 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6243 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6244 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6245 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6246 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6247 // branch of the if, below.
6248 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6249 << dcl;
6250 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6251
6252 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6253 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6254 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6255 .getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006256 }
6257
6258 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006259 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6260 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6261 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6262 if (isSFINAEContext())
6263 return QualType();
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006264 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op))
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006265 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Chris Lattner93b28362010-07-05 19:36:34 +00006266 else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006267 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006268 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006269 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006270 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006271 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6272 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006273 return QualType();
6274 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006275 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006276 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6277 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6278 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006279 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006280 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006281 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006282 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006283 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006284 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006285 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6286 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6287 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6288 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6289 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006290 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6291 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006292 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6293 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006294 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6295 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006296 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006297 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006298 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6299 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006300 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006301 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6302 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006303 return QualType();
6304 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006305 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006306 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006307 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006308 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006309 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6310 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006311 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006312 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006313 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6314 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006315 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006316 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6317 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6318 return QualType();
6319 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006320
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006321 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6322 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006323 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006324 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006325 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006326 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006327 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006328 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6329 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006330 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6331 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6332 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006333 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006334 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006335
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006336 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6337 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6338 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6339 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6340 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6341 }
6342
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006343 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006344 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6345 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006346 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006347}
6348
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006349/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006350QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006351 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6352 return Context.DependentTy;
6353
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006354 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006355 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6356 QualType Result;
6357
6358 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6359 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6360 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6361 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6362 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6363 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6364 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6365 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6366 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006367
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006368 if (Result.isNull()) {
6369 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6370 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6371 return QualType();
6372 }
6373
6374 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006375}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006376
6377static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6378 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6379 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6380 switch (Kind) {
6381 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006382 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6383 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006384 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6385 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6386 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6387 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6388 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6389 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6390 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6391 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6392 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6393 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6394 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6395 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6396 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6397 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6398 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6399 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6400 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6401 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6402 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6403 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6404 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6405 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6406 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6407 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6408 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6409 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6410 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6411 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6412 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6413 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6414 }
6415 return Opc;
6416}
6417
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006418static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6419 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6420 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6421 switch (Kind) {
6422 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6423 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6424 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6425 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6426 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6427 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6428 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6429 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6430 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006431 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6432 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006433 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006434 }
6435 return Opc;
6436}
6437
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006438/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6439/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6440/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006441Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6442 unsigned Op,
6443 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006444 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006445 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006446 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6447 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6448 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006449
6450 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006451 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6452 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6453 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006454 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6455 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6456 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6457 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6458 break;
6459 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006460 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006461 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6462 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006463 break;
6464 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6465 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6466 break;
6467 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6468 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6469 break;
6470 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6471 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6472 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006473 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006474 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6475 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6476 break;
6477 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6478 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6479 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6480 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006481 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006482 break;
6483 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6484 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006485 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006486 break;
6487 case BinaryOperator::And:
6488 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6489 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6490 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6491 break;
6492 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6493 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006494 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006495 break;
6496 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6497 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006498 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6499 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006500 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6501 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6502 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006503 break;
6504 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006505 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6506 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6507 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6508 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006509 break;
6510 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006511 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6512 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6513 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006514 break;
6515 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006516 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6517 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6518 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006519 break;
6520 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6521 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006522 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6523 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6524 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6525 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006526 break;
6527 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6528 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6529 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006530 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6531 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6532 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6533 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006534 break;
6535 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6536 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6537 break;
6538 }
6539 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006540 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006541 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
6542 if (Opc >= BinaryOperator::Assign && Opc <= BinaryOperator::OrAssign)
6543 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6544 << ResultTy;
6545 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006546 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006547 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6548 else
6549 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006550 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6551 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006552}
6553
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006554/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6555/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006556static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6557 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006558 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6559 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6560 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006561 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006562 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6563
6564 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6565 return;
6566
6567 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6568 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6569 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006570 return;
6571 }
6572
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006573 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6574 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006575 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006576
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006577 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006578 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006579
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006580 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6581 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6582 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6583 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006584 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006585 return;
6586 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006587
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006588 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006589 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6590 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006591}
6592
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006593/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6594/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6595/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6596/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006597static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6598 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006599 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6600 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6601 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6602 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006603 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006604 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006605 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6606
6607 // Subs are not binary operators.
6608 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6609 return;
6610
6611 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6612 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006613 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6614 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006615 return;
6616
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006617 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006618 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006619 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006620 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6621 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006622 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006623 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006624 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6625 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6626 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6627 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006628 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006629 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006630 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006631 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6632 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006633 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006634 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006635 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6636 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6637 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6638 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006639}
6640
6641/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6642/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6643/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6644static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6645 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006646 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006647 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6648}
6649
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006650// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006651Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6652 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6653 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006654 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006655 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006656
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006657 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6658 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006659
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006660 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6661 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6662
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006663 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6664}
6665
6666Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6667 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6668 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006669 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006670 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006671 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6672 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6673 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6674 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6675 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006676 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006677 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006678 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6679 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6680 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006681
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006682 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6683 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006684 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006685 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006686
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006687 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006688 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006689}
6690
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006691Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006692 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006693 ExprArg InputArg) {
6694 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006695
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006696 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006697 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006698 QualType resultType;
6699 switch (Opc) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006700 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6701 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006702 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6703 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006704 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006705 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006706 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6707 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6708 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006709 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006710 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006711 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006712 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006713 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006714 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006715 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006716 break;
6717 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6718 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006719 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6720 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006721 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6722 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006723 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6724 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006725 break;
6726 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6727 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6728 break;
6729 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6730 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6731 resultType->isPointerType())
6732 break;
6733
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006734 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6735 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006736 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006737 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6738 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006739 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6740 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006741 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6742 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6743 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006744 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006745 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006746 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006747 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6748 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006749 break;
6750 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006751 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006752 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006753 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006754 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6755 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006756 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006757 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6758 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006759 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006760 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6761 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006762 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006763 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006764 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006765 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006766 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006767 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006768 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006769 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006770 }
6771 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006772 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006773
6774 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006775 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006776}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006777
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006778Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6779 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6780 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006781 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006782 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6783 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006784 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6785 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6786 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6787 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006788 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006789 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006790 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6791 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6792 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006793
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006794 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6795 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006796
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006797 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6798}
6799
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006800// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6801Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6802 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6803 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6804}
6805
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006806/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006807Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6808 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6809 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006810 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006811 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006812
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006813 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6814 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006815 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006816 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006817
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006818 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006819 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6820 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006821}
6822
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006823Sema::OwningExprResult
6824Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6825 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6826 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006827 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6828 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6829
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006830 bool isFileScope
6831 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006832 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006833 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006834
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006835 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6836 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6837 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006838
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006839 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6840 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6841 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006842
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006843 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6844 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6845 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6846 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6847 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006848
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006849 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006850 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006851 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006852
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006853 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6854 // expressions are not lvalues.
6855
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006856 substmt.release();
6857 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006858}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006859
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006860Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6861 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006862 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6863 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006864 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6865 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006867 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006868
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006869 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6870 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6871 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006872 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006873 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6874 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6875
6876 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6877 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6878 if (!Dependent
6879 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6880 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6881 << TypeRange))
6882 return ExprError();
6883
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006884 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6885 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006886 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6887 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006888 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006889 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6890 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006891
6892 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6893 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6894 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6895 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6896 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6897 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6898 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6899 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6900 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6901 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6902 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6903 if(!AT)
6904 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6905 << CurrentType);
6906 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6907 } else
6908 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6909
6910 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6911 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6912 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6913 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6914 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6915 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6916 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6917 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6918
6919 // Record this array index.
6920 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6921 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6922 continue;
6923 }
6924
6925 // Offset of a field.
6926 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6927 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6928 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6929 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6930 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6931 continue;
6932 }
6933
6934 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6935 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6936 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6937 return ExprError();
6938
6939 // Look for the designated field.
6940 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6941 if (!RC)
6942 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6943 << CurrentType);
6944 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6945
6946 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6947 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6948 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6949 // (clause 9).
6950 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6951 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6952 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6953 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6954 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6955 << CurrentType))
6956 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6957 }
6958
6959 // Look for the field.
6960 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6961 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6962 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6963 if (!MemberDecl)
6964 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6965 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6966 OC.LocEnd));
6967
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006968 // C99 7.17p3:
6969 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6970 //
6971 // We diagnose this as an error.
6972 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6973 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6974 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6975 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6976 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6977 return ExprError();
6978 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006979
6980 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
6981 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
6982 if (AnonStructUnion) {
6983 do {
6984 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
6985 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
6986 }
6987
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006988 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6989 // the base class indirections.
6990 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6991 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006992 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006993 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6994 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6995 B != BEnd; ++B)
6996 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6997 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00006998
6999 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007000 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7001 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7002 unsigned n = Path.size();
7003 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7004 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7005 } else {
7006 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7007 }
7008 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7009 }
7010
7011 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7012 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7013 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7014}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007015
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007016Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
7017 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7018 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7019 TypeTy *argty,
7020 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7021 unsigned NumComponents,
7022 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7023
7024 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7025 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7026 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7027 return ExprError();
7028
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007029 if (!ArgTInfo)
7030 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7031
7032 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7033 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007034}
7035
7036
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007037Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7038 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
7039 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007040 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7041 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7042 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7043 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007044
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007045 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007046
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007047 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7048}
7049
7050Sema::OwningExprResult
7051Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7052 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7053 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7054 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007055 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7056 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7057 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7058 return ExprError();
7059 }
7060
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007061 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007062 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007063}
7064
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007065
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007066Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7067 ExprArg cond,
7068 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
7069 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7070 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
7071 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
7072 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007073
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007074 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7075
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007076 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007077 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007078 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007079 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007080 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007081 } else {
7082 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7083 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7084 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7085 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007086 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7087 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7088 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007089
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007090 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7091 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007092 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7093 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007094 }
7095
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007096 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
7097 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007098 resType, RPLoc,
7099 resType->isDependentType(),
7100 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007101}
7102
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007103//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7104// Clang Extensions.
7105//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7106
7107/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007108void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007109 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7110 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7111 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007112 if (BlockScope)
7113 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7114 else
7115 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007116}
7117
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007118void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007119 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007120 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007121
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007122 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007123 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007124 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007125
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007126 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007127 QualType RetTy;
7128 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007129 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007130 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007131 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007132 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7133 } else {
7134 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007135 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007136 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007137
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007139
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007140 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7141 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7142 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007143 return;
7144 }
7145
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007146 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7147 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7148 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7149 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7150 return;
7151 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007152
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007153 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007154 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7155 // ^ * { ... }
7156 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007157 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7158 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007159
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007160 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007161 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007162 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7163 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7164 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7165 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007166 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7167 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7168 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7169 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7170 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007171 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007172 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007173
7174 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7175 // ^ fntype { ... }
7176 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7177 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7178 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7179 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7180 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7181 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7182 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007183 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007184 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007185 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007186
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007187 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7188 if (!Params.empty())
7189 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007190
7191 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007192 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007193
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007194 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007195 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7196 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7197 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7198 }
7199
7200 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7201 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007202 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007203 return;
7204
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007205 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7206 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7207
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007208 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007209 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7210 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7211
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007212 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007213 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7214 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7215 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7216
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007217 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007218 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007219 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007220}
7221
7222/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7223/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7224void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007225 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007226 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007227 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007228 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007229}
7230
7231/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7232/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007233Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7234 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007235 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7236 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7237 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007238
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007239 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007240
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007241 PopDeclContext();
7242
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007243 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007244 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7245 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007246
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007247 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007248 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007249
7250 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7251 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7252 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7253
7254 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7255 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7256
7257 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7258 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7259 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7260 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7261
7262 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7263 // preserve its sugar structure.
7264 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7265 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7266 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7267
7268 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7269 } else {
7270 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7271 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7272 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7273 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7274 FPT->isVariadic(),
7275 /*quals*/ 0,
7276 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7277 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7278 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7279 FPT->exception_begin(),
7280 Ext);
7281 }
7282
7283 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7284 } else {
7285 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7286 false, false, 0, 0,
7287 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7288 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007289
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007290 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007291 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7292 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007293 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007294
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007295 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007296 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007297 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007298
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007299 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007300
7301 bool Good = true;
7302 // Check goto/label use.
7303 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7304 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7305 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7306
7307 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7308 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7309 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7310 continue;
7311
7312 // Emit error.
7313 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7314 Good = false;
7315 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007316 if (!Good) {
7317 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007318 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007319 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007320
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007321 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007322 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7323 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7324 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007325
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007326 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7327 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007328 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007329 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007330}
7331
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007332Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7333 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7334 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007335 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7336 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
7337 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, move(expr), TInfo, RPLoc);
7338}
7339
7340Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7341 ExprArg expr, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7342 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007343 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7344 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007345
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007346 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007347
7348 // Get the va_list type
7349 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007350 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7351 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7352 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7353 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007354 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007355 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7356 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7357 } else {
7358 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7359 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007360 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007361 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007362 return ExprError();
7363 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007364
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007365 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7366 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007367 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7368 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007369 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007370 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007371
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007372 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007373 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007374
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007375 expr.release();
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007376 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7377 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007378}
7379
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007380Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007381 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7382 // pointers on the target.
7383 QualType Ty;
7384 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7385 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7386 else
7387 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7388
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007389 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007390}
7391
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007392static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007393 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007394 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7395 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007396
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007397 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7398 if (!PT)
7399 return;
7400
7401 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7402 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7403 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7404 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7405 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7406 return;
7407 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007408
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007409 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7410 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7411 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7412 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007413
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007414 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007415}
7416
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007417bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7418 SourceLocation Loc,
7419 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007420 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7421 bool *Complained) {
7422 if (Complained)
7423 *Complained = false;
7424
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007425 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7426 bool isInvalid = false;
7427 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007428 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007429
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007430 switch (ConvTy) {
7431 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7432 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007433 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007434 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7435 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007436 case IntToPointer:
7437 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7438 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007439 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007440 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007441 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7442 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007443 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7444 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7445 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007446 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7447 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7448 break;
7449 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007450 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7451 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7452 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7453 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7454 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7455 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7456 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7457 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7458 // C++ semantics.
7459 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7460 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7461 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007462 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7463 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007464 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007465 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007466 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007467 case IntToBlockPointer:
7468 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7469 break;
7470 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007471 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007472 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007473 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007474 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007475 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7476 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7477 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007478 case IncompatibleVectors:
7479 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7480 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007481 case Incompatible:
7482 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7483 isInvalid = true;
7484 break;
7485 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007486
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007487 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7488 switch (Action) {
7489 case AA_Assigning:
7490 case AA_Initializing:
7491 // The destination type comes first.
7492 FirstType = DstType;
7493 SecondType = SrcType;
7494 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007495
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007496 case AA_Returning:
7497 case AA_Passing:
7498 case AA_Converting:
7499 case AA_Sending:
7500 case AA_Casting:
7501 // The source type comes first.
7502 FirstType = SrcType;
7503 SecondType = DstType;
7504 break;
7505 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007506
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007507 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007508 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007509 if (Complained)
7510 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007511 return isInvalid;
7512}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007513
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007514bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007515 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7516 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7517 if (Result)
7518 *Result = ICEResult;
7519 return false;
7520 }
7521
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007522 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7523
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007524 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007525 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7526 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7527
7528 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7529 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7530 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7531 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7532 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7533 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7534 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007535
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007536 return true;
7537 }
7538
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007539 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7540 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007541
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007542 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7543 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7544 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007545
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007546 if (Result)
7547 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7548 return false;
7549}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007550
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007551void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007552Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007553 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7554 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007555}
7556
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007557void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007558Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7559 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7560 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7561 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007562
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007563 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7564 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7565 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7566 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7567 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007568 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007569 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7570 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7571 I != IEnd; ++I)
7572 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7573 }
7574
7575 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7576 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7577 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7578 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7579 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7580 I != IEnd; ++I)
7581 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7582 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007583 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007584
7585 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7586 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7587 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7588 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007590 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7591 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7592 ExprTemporaries.end());
7593
7594 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7595 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007596}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007597
7598/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7599///
7600/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7601/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7602/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7603/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7604///
7605/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7606///
7607/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7608void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7609 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007610
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007611 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007612 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007613
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007614 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7615 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7616 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7617 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007618 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007619 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007620 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007621 return;
7622 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007623
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007624 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7625 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007626
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007627 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7628 // an instantiation.
7629 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7630 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007631
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007632 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007633 case Unevaluated:
7634 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7635 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007636
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007637 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7638 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7639 // "used"; handle this below.
7640 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007641
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007642 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7643 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7644 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7645 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007646 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007647 return;
7648 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007649
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007650 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007651 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007652 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007653 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007654 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007655 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007656 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007657 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007658 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007659 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7660 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007661
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007662 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007663 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007664 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007665 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007666 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7667 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007668 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7669 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7670 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007671 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007672 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007673 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7674 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007675 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007676 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007677 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007678 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007679 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007680 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7681 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7682 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7683 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7684 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007685 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007686 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007687 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007688 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007689 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7690 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7691 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007692 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007693 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007694 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7695 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007696
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007697 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7698 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7699 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7700 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7701 Loc));
7702 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007703 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007704 Loc));
7705 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007706 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007707
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007708 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007709 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007710
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007711 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007712 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007713
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007714 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007715 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007716 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007717 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7718 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7719 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7720 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7721 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7722 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7723 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7724 }
7725 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007726
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007727 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007728
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007729 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007730 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007731 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007732}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007733
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007734namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007735 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007736 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007737 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007738 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7739 Sema &S;
7740 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007741
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007742 public:
7743 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007744
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007745 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007746
7747 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7748 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007749 };
7750}
7751
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007752bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7753 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007754 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7755 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7756 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007757
7758 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007759}
7760
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007761bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007762 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7763 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7764 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007765 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7766 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007767 }
7768
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007769 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007770}
7771
7772void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7773 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007774 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007775}
7776
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007777/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7778/// of the program being compiled.
7779///
7780/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007781/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007782/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7783/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7784/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7785/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007786/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007787/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007788///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007789/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7790/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7791/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7792/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007793bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007794 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7795 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7796 case Unevaluated:
7797 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7798 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007799
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007800 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7801 Diag(Loc, PD);
7802 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007803
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007804 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7805 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7806 break;
7807 }
7808
7809 return false;
7810}
7811
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007812bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7813 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7814 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7815 return false;
7816
7817 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7818 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7819 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7820 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007821
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007822 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007823 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007824 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7825 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007826 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007827 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7828 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7829 return true;
7830
7831 return false;
7832}
7833
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007834// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7835// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7836void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7837 SourceLocation Loc;
7838
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007839 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7840
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007841 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7842 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7843 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7844 return;
7845
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007846 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7847 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7848 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7849 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7850
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007851 // self = [<foo> init...]
7852 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7853 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7854 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7855
7856 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7857 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7858 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7859 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7860 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007861
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007862 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7863 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7864 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7865 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7866 return;
7867
7868 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7869 } else {
7870 // Not an assignment.
7871 return;
7872 }
7873
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007874 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007875 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007876
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007877 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007878 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007879 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007880 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7881 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7882 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007883}
7884
7885bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7886 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7887
7888 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007889 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007890
7891 QualType T = E->getType();
7892
7893 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7894 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7895 return true;
7896 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7897 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7898 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7899 return true;
7900 }
7901 }
7902
7903 return false;
7904}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007905
7906Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7907 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007908 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7909 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007910 return ExprError();
7911
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007912 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007913 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007914
7915 return Owned(Sub);
7916}